blob: 0bc58ef21c7161974e7e97df59907b81410bd5f2 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000032#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
33#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000035#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000037#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000038using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000039using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000040
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000041
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000042/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
43/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
44///
45/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
46/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
47/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
48/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
49/// function is being used.
50///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000051/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
52/// decls.
53///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000054/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
55/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000056///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000059 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000060 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000061 }
62
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 // See if the decl is unavailable
64 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek042411c2010-07-21 20:43:11 +000065 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000066 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
67 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000068
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000069 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000070 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000071 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
72 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
73 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
74 return true;
75 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000076 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000077
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000078 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000079}
80
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000081/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000082/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000083/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
84///
85void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000086 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000087 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000088 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000089 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000090
91 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
92 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000093 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
94 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000095
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000096 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
97 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000098 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +000099 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
100 int isMethod = 0;
101 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
102 // skip over named parameters.
103 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
104 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
105 if (nullPos)
106 --nullPos;
107 else
108 ++i;
109 }
110 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
111 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000112 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000113 // skip over named parameters.
114 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
115 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
116 if (nullPos)
117 --nullPos;
118 else
119 ++i;
120 }
121 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000122 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000123 // block or function pointer call.
124 QualType Ty = V->getType();
125 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000126 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000127 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
128 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000129 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
130 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
131 unsigned k;
132 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
133 if (nullPos)
134 --nullPos;
135 else
136 ++i;
137 }
138 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
139 }
140 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
141 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000142 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000143 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000144 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000145 return;
146
147 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000148 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000149 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000150 return;
151 }
152 int sentinel = i;
153 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
154 --sentinelPos;
155 ++i;
156 }
157 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
158 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000159 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000160 return;
161 }
162 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
163 ++i;
164 ++sentinel;
165 }
166 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000167 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
168 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
169 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000170 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000171 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
172 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
173 return;
174
175 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
176 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
177
178 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
179 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000180}
181
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000182SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
183 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
184 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
185}
186
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000187//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
188// Standard Promotions and Conversions
189//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
190
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000191/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
192void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
193 QualType Ty = E->getType();
194 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
195
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000196 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000197 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000198 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000199 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
200 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
201 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
202 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
203 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
204 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
205 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000206 //
207 // C++ 4.2p1:
208 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
209 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
210 //
211 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
212 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000213 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000214 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000215 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000216}
217
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
219 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000220
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000221 QualType Ty = E->getType();
222 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
223 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
224 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
225 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
226 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
227 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
228 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
229 // rvalue is T
230 //
231 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000232 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
233 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000234 // type of the lvalue.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000235 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000236 }
237}
238
239
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000240/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000241/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000242/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
243/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
244/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
245Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
246 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
247 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000248
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000249 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
250 //
251 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
252 // unsigned int may be used:
253 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
254 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
255 // and unsigned int.
256 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
257 //
258 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
259 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
260 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
261 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
263 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000264 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000265 return Expr;
266 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000268 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000269 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000270 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000271 }
272
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000273 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000274 return Expr;
275}
276
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000277/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000278/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000279/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
280void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
281 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
282 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000283
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000284 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000285 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
286 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000287 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000288
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000289 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
290}
291
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000292/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
293/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
294/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
295/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000296bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
297 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000298 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000299
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000300 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
301 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
302 // etc.
303 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
304 return false;
305
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000306 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000307 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
308 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
309 << Expr->getType() << CT))
310 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000311
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000312 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000313 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000314 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
315 << Expr->getType() << CT))
316 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000317
318 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000319}
320
321
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
323/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000324/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000325/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
326/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
327/// GCC.
328QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
329 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000330 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000331 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000332
333 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000334
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000335 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000336 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 QualType lhs =
338 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000339 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000340 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000341
342 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
343 if (lhs == rhs)
344 return lhs;
345
346 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
347 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
348 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
349 return lhs;
350
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000351 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000355 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000356 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
357 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
358
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000359 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000360 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000361 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
362 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000363 return destType;
364}
365
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000366//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
367// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
368//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
369
370
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000371/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000372/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
373/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
374/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
375/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000376///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000377ExprResult
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000378Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000379 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
380
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000381 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000382 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000383 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000384
385 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
386 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
387 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000389 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000390 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000391 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392
393 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000394 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000395 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000396
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000397 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
398 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
399 // strings.
400 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000401 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000402 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000403
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000404 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000405 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattner2085fd62009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000406 Literal.GetStringLength(),
407 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
408 &StringTokLocs[0],
409 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000410}
411
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000412/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
413/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
414/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
415/// for values inside the block or for globals).
416///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000417/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000418/// up-to-date.
419///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000420static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000421 ValueDecl *VD) {
422 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
423 // we wanted to.
424 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
425 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000426
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000427 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
428 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
429 return false;
430
431 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
432 // snapshot it.
433 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
434 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
436 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000437
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000438 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
439 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
440
441 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
442 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
443 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
444 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
446 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000448 if (!NextBlock)
449 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000450
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000451 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
452 // having a reference outside it.
453 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
454 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000455
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000456 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
457 // a snapshot as well.
458 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
459 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000460
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000462}
463
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000464
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000465ExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000466Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000467 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000468 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
469 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
470}
471
472/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000473ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000474Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
475 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
476 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000477 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000478 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000479 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000480 << D->getDeclName();
481 return ExprError();
482 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000485 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
486 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
487 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000488 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000489 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000490 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
491 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000492 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
493 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000494 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000495 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000496 << D->getIdentifier();
497 return ExprError();
498 }
499 }
500 }
501 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000502
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000503 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000504
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000505 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
506 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
507 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000508 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000509}
510
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000511/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
512/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
513/// actual member.
514///
515/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
516/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
517/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
518/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
519/// we found.
520///
521/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
522/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
523/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
524VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
525 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000526 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
527 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
528 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
529
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000530 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000531 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
532 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
533 do {
534 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000535 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000536 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000537 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000538 else {
539 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
540 break;
541 }
542 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000543 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000544 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000545
546 return BaseObject;
547}
548
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000549ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000550Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
551 FieldDecl *Field,
552 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
553 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
554 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000555 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000556 AnonFields);
557
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000558 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
559 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
560 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
561 // found via name lookup.
562 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000563 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000564 if (BaseObject) {
565 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
566 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000567 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000568 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000569 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
573 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
574 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
575 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
576 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000577 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
579 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
580 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000581 BaseQuals
582 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000583 } else {
584 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
585 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
586 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000587 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
588 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000589 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000590 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000591 = Context.getTagDeclType(
592 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
593 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000594 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
596 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
597 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000598 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000599 MD->getThisType(Context),
600 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000601 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
602 }
603 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000604 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
605 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000606 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 }
609
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000610 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000611 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
612 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 }
614
615 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
616 // anonymous struct/union.
617 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000618 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000619 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
620 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
621 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
622 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000623 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
624 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
625
626 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
627 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
628 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
629 ResultQuals.removeConst();
630
631 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
632 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
633
634 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
635 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
636
637 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
638 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
639 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
640
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000641 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000642 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000643 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000644 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
645 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000646 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000647 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000648 }
649
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000650 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000651}
652
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000653/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000654/// possibly a list of template arguments.
655///
656/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
657/// DecomposeTemplateName.
658///
659/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
660/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
661/// some way.
662static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
663 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
664 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000665 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000666 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
667 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
668 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
669 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
670
671 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
672 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
673 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
674 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
675 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
676
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000677 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000678 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
679 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000680 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
681 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000682 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000683 TemplateArgs = 0;
684 }
685}
686
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000687/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
688/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
689/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000690static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000691 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
692 return false;
693
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000694 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
695 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
696 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
697 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
698 if (!BaseRT) return false;
699
700 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000701 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000702 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
703 return false;
704 }
705
706 return true;
707}
708
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000709/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
710/// the prospective base classes.
711static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
712 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
713 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000714 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000715 return false;
716
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000717 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000718 if (!RD) return false;
719 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
720
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000721 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
722 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
723 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
724 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
725 if (!BaseRT) return false;
726
727 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000728 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
729 return false;
730 }
731
732 return true;
733}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000734
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000735enum IMAKind {
736 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
737 IMA_Static,
738
739 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
740 IMA_Mixed,
741
742 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
743 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
744 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
745
746 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
747 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
748 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
749
750 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
751 IMA_Instance,
752
753 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
754 IMA_Unresolved,
755
756 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
757 /// context is not an instance method.
758 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
759
760 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
761 /// non-class context.
762 IMA_AnonymousMember,
763
764 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
765 /// context is not an instance method.
766 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
767
768 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
769 /// class.
770 IMA_Error_Unrelated
771};
772
773/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
774/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
775/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
776/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
777/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
778/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
779static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
780 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000781 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000782
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000783 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000784 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000785 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
786 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000787
788 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
789 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
790
791 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
792 bool hasNonInstance = false;
793 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
794 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000795 NamedDecl *D = *I;
796 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000797 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
798
799 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
800 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
801 // that's a special case.
802 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
803 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
804 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
805 }
806 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
807 }
808 else
809 hasNonInstance = true;
810 }
811
812 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
813 // member reference.
814 if (Classes.empty())
815 return IMA_Static;
816
817 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
818 // an implicit member reference.
819 if (isStaticContext)
820 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
821
822 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
823 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
824 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
825 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000826 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000827 Classes))
828 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
829
830 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
831}
832
833/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
834static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
835 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
836 const LookupResult &R) {
837 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
838 SourceRange Range(Loc);
839 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
840
841 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
842 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
843 if (MD->isStatic()) {
844 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
845 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
846 << Range << R.getLookupName();
847 return;
848 }
849 }
850
851 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
852 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
853 return;
854 }
855
856 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000857}
858
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000859/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
860///
861/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000862bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
863 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000864 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
865
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000866 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000867 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000868 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
869 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000870 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000871 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000872 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
873 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000874
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000875 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
876 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
877 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
878 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000879 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000880 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
882 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
883
884 if (!R.empty()) {
885 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
886 R.suppressDiagnostics();
887
888 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
889 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
890 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
891 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
892
893 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
894 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
895 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000896 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000897 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
898 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000899 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000900 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000901 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000902 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
903 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
904 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
905 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
906 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
907 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
908 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
909 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
910 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
911 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
912 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
913 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
914 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
915 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000916 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000917 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
918 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
919 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000920 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000921 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000922 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000923 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000924
925 // Do we really want to note all of these?
926 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
927 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
928
929 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
930 return false;
931 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000932
933 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000934 }
935 }
936
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000937 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000938 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000939 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000940 if (!R.empty()) {
941 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
942 if (SS.isEmpty())
943 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
944 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
945 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
946 else
947 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
948 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
949 << SS.getRange()
950 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
951 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
952 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
953 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
954 << ND->getDeclName();
955
956 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
957 return false;
958 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000959
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000960 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
961 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
962 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
963 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
964 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
965 // to recover well anyway.
966 if (SS.isEmpty())
967 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
968 else
969 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
970 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
971 << SS.getRange();
972
973 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
974 return true;
975 }
976 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000977 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000978 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000979 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000980 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000981 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000982 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000983 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
984 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000985 return true;
986 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000987 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000988 }
989
990 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
991 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
992 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
993 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
994 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
995 << SS.getRange();
996 return true;
997 }
998
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000999 // Give up, we can't recover.
1000 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1001 return true;
1002}
1003
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001004static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001005 IdentifierInfo *II,
1006 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001007 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1008 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1009 if (!IDecl)
1010 return 0;
1011 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1012 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1013 return 0;
1014 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1015 if (!property)
1016 return 0;
1017 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1018 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1019 return 0;
1020 return property;
1021}
1022
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001023static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001024 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001025 IdentifierInfo *II,
1026 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1027 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001028 bool LookForIvars;
1029 if (Lookup.empty())
1030 LookForIvars = true;
1031 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1032 LookForIvars = false;
1033 else
1034 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1035 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1036 if (!LookForIvars)
1037 return 0;
1038
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001039 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1040 if (!IDecl)
1041 return 0;
1042 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001043 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1044 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001045 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1046 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1047 if (!property)
1048 return 0;
1049 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1050 DynamicImplSeen =
1051 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1052 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001053 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1054 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001055 NameLoc,
1056 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1057 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1058 (Expr *)0, true);
1059 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1060 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1061 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1062 return Ivar;
1063 }
1064 return 0;
1065}
1066
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001067ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001068 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1069 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1070 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1071 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001072 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1073 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1074
1075 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001076 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001077
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001078 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001079
1080 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001081 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001083 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001084
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001085 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001086 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001087 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001088
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001089 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1090 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001091 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1092 // (note: handled after lookup)
1093 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1094 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1095 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001096 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1097 // names a dependent type.
1098 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1099 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001100 bool DependentID = false;
1101 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1102 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1103 DependentID = true;
1104 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1105 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1106 if (DC) {
1107 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1108 return ExprError();
1109 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1110 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1111 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1112 } else {
1113 DependentID = true;
1114 }
1115 }
1116
1117 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001118 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001119 TemplateArgs);
1120 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001121 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001122 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001123 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001124 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001125 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1126 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1127 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1128 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1129 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001130 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1131 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1132 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001133 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001134 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001135 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001136
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001137 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1138 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001139 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001140 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001141 if (E.isInvalid())
1142 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001143
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001144 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1145 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001146 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1147 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001148 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001149 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1150 isAddressOfOperand);
1151 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001152 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1153 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001154 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001155 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001156
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001157 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1158 return ExprError();
1159
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001160 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1161 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001162 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001163
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001164 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001165 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001166 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1167 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1168 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1169 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1170 }
1171
1172 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1173 // call, diagnose the problem.
1174 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001175 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001176 return ExprError();
1177
1178 assert(!R.empty() &&
1179 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001180
1181 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1182 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001183 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001184 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1185 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001186 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001187 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1188 return move(E);
1189 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001190 }
1191 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001192
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001193 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1194 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1195
1196 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001197 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001198 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1199 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001200 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1201 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1202 if (Property) {
1203 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1204 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001205 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001206 }
1207 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001208 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001209 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1210 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1211 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1212 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1213 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1214 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001215 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001216 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001217
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001218 QualType T = Func->getType();
1219 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001220 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001221 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1222 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001223 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001224 }
1225 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001226
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001227 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001228 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1229 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1230 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1231 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1232 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1233 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1234 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1235 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
1236 // So if we found a class member with an expression of form other
1237 // than &A::foo, we have to try to build an implicit member expr.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001238 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001239 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001240 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1241 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001242 }
1243
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001244 if (TemplateArgs)
1245 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001246
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001247 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1248}
1249
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001250/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001251ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001252Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1253 LookupResult &R,
1254 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1255 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1256 case IMA_Instance:
1257 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1258
1259 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1260 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1261 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1262 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1263
1264 case IMA_Mixed:
1265 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1266 case IMA_Unresolved:
1267 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1268
1269 case IMA_Static:
1270 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1271 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1272 if (TemplateArgs)
1273 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1274 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1275
1276 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1277 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1278 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1279 return ExprError();
1280 }
1281
1282 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1283 return ExprError();
1284}
1285
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001286/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1287/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1288/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1289/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001290ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001291Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001292 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001293 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001294 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001295 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001296
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001297 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001298 return ExprError();
1299
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001300 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001301 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1302
1303 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1304 return ExprError();
1305
1306 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001307 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1308 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001309 return ExprError();
1310 }
1311
1312 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1313}
1314
1315/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1316/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1317/// additional lookup.
1318///
1319/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1320/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1321///
1322/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001323ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001324Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001325 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001326 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001327 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001328
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001329 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1330 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1331 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1332 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1333 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1334
1335 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1336 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1337 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001338 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001339
1340 bool LookForIvars;
1341 if (Lookup.empty())
1342 LookForIvars = true;
1343 else if (IsClassMethod)
1344 LookForIvars = false;
1345 else
1346 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1347 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001348 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001349 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001350 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001351 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1352 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1353 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1354 if (IsClassMethod)
1355 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1356 << IV->getDeclName());
1357
1358 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1359 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1360 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1361 return ExprError();
1362
1363 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1364 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1365 return ExprError();
1366
1367 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1368 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1369 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1370 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1371
1372 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1373 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1374 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1375 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001376 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001377 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001378 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001379 SelfName, false, false);
1380 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1381 return Owned(new (Context)
1382 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1383 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1384 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001385 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001386 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001387 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001388 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1389 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1390 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1391 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1392 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1393 }
1394 }
1395
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001396 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1397 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1398 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1399 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1400 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1401 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1402 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1403 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1404 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1405 }
1406 }
1407 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001408 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1409 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001410}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001411
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001412/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1413///
1414/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1415///
1416/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1417/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1418/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1419/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1420///
1421/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1422/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1423/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1424/// the class declaring the member.
1425///
1426/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1427/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1428/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001429bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001430Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1431 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001432 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001433 NamedDecl *Member) {
1434 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1435 if (!RD)
1436 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001437
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001438 QualType DestRecordType;
1439 QualType DestType;
1440 QualType FromRecordType;
1441 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1442 bool PointerConversions = false;
1443 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1444 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001445
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001446 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1447 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1448 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1449 PointerConversions = true;
1450 } else {
1451 DestType = DestRecordType;
1452 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001453 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001454 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1455 if (Method->isStatic())
1456 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001457
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001458 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1459 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001460
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001461 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1462 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1463 PointerConversions = true;
1464 } else {
1465 FromRecordType = FromType;
1466 DestType = DestRecordType;
1467 }
1468 } else {
1469 // No conversion necessary.
1470 return false;
1471 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001472
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001473 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1474 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001475
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001476 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1477 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1478 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001479
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001480 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1481 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1482
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001483 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001484
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001485 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001486 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001487 // class name.
1488 //
1489 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1490 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1491 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1492 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1493 //
1494 // class Base { public: int x; };
1495 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1496 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1497 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1498 //
1499 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1500 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1501 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1502 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001503 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001504 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1505 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1506 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1507
1508 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1509
1510 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1511 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1512 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1513 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001514 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001515 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001516 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001517 return true;
1518
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001519 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001520 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001521 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1522 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001523
1524 FromType = QType;
1525 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1526
1527 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1528 // we're done.
1529 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1530 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001531 }
1532 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001533
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001534 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001535
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001536 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1537 // down to the using declaration's type.
1538 //
1539 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1540 // class ever has member declarations.
1541 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1542 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1543 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1544 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1545
1546 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1547 // conversion is non-trivial.
1548 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1549 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001550 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001551 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001552 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001553 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001554
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001555 QualType UType = URecordType;
1556 if (PointerConversions)
1557 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001558 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001559 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001560 FromType = UType;
1561 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1562 }
1563
1564 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1565 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1566 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001567 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001568
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001569 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001570 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1571 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001572 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001573 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001574
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001575 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001576 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001577 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001578}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001579
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001580/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001581static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001582 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001583 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001584 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1585 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001586 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1587 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1588 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001589 if (SS.isSet()) {
1590 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1591 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001592 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001593
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001594 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001595 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1596 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001597}
1598
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001599/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1600/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1601/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1602/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001603ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001604Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1605 LookupResult &R,
1606 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1607 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001608 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1609
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001610 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001611
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001612 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1613 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001614 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001615 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001616 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001617 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001618 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001619
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001620 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1621 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001622 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1623 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001624 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1625 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001626 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1627 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1628 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1629 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001630 }
1631
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001632 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001633 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1634 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001635 SS,
1636 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1637 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001638}
1639
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001640bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001641 const LookupResult &R,
1642 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001643 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1644 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1645 return false;
1646
1647 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001648 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001649 return false;
1650
1651 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001652 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001653 return false;
1654
1655 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1656 // normal lookup:
1657 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1658 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1659
1660 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1661 // -- a declaration of a class member
1662 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1663 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001664 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001665 return false;
1666
1667 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1668 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1669 // using-declaration
1670 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1671 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1672 // turn off ADL anyway).
1673 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1674 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1675 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1676 return false;
1677
1678 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1679 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1680 // template
1681 // And also for builtin functions.
1682 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1683 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1684
1685 // But also builtin functions.
1686 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1687 return false;
1688 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1689 return false;
1690 }
1691
1692 return true;
1693}
1694
1695
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001696/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1697/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1698/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1699/// will in fact be used.
1700static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1701 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1702 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1703 return true;
1704 }
1705
1706 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1707 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1708 return true;
1709 }
1710
1711 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1712 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1713 return true;
1714 }
1715
1716 return false;
1717}
1718
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001719ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001720Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001721 LookupResult &R,
1722 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001723 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1724 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001725 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001726 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1727 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001728
1729 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1730 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1731 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001732 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1733 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001734 return ExprError();
1735
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001736 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1737 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1738 // we've picked a target.
1739 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1740
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001741 bool Dependent
1742 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001743 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001744 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001745 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001746 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001747 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1748 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001749
1750 return Owned(ULE);
1751}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001752
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001753
1754/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001755ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001756Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001757 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1758 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001759 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001760 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1761 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001762
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001763 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001764 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1765 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001766
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001767 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1768 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1769 // a template argument list.
1770 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1771 << Template << SS.getRange();
1772 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1773 return ExprError();
1774 }
1775
1776 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1777 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1778 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001779 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001780 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001781 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001782 return ExprError();
1783 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001784
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001785 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1786 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1787 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1788 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001789 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001790 return ExprError();
1791
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001792 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1793 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001794 return ExprError();
1795
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001796 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1797 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1798 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1799 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001800 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001801 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1802 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1803 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001804 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001805 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001806 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1807 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1808 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1809 return ExprError();
1810 }
1811
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001812 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001813 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1814 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1815 return ExprError();
1816 }
1817
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001818 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001819 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001820 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001821 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001822 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001823 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1824 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001825 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001826
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001827 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001828 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001829 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1830 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001831 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001832 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1833 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1834 Expr *E = new (Context)
1835 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1836 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001837
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001838 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001839 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001840 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001841 SourceLocation(),
1842 Owned(E));
1843 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001844 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001845 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1846 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1847 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001848 }
1849 }
1850 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001851 }
1852 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1853 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001854
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001855 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1856 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001857}
1858
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001859ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001860 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001861 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001862
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001863 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001864 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001865 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1866 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1867 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001868 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001869
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001870 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1871 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001872
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001873 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001874 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1875 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001876 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001877 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001878 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001879 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001880
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001881 QualType ResTy;
1882 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1883 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1884 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001885 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001886
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001887 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001888 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001889 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1890 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001891 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001892}
1893
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001894ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001895 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001896 bool Invalid = false;
1897 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1898 if (Invalid)
1899 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001900
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001901 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1902 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001903 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001904 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001905
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001906 QualType Ty;
1907 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1908 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1909 else if (Literal.isWide())
1910 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001911 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1912 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001913 else
1914 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001915
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001916 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1917 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001918 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001919}
1920
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001921ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001922 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001923 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1924 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001925 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001926 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001927 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001928 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001929 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001930
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001931 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001932 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1933 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001934 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001935
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001936 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001937 bool Invalid = false;
1938 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1939 if (Invalid)
1940 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001941
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001942 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001943 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1944 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001945 return ExprError();
1946
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001947 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001948
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001949 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001950 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001951 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001952 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001953 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001954 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001955 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001956 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001957
1958 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1959
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001960 using llvm::APFloat;
1961 APFloat Val(Format);
1962
1963 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001964
1965 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1966 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1967 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1968 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001969 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001970 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001971 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001972 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001973 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1974 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001975 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001976 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1977 }
1978
1979 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1980 << Ty
1981 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1982 }
1983
1984 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattner001d64d2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001985 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001986
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001987 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001988 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001989 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001990 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001991
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001992 // long long is a C99 feature.
1993 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001994 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001995 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1996
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001997 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001998 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001999
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002000 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2001 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2002 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002003 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2004 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002005 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002006 } else {
2007 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2008 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002009
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002010 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2011 // be an unsigned int.
2012 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2013
2014 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002015 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002016 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2017 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002018 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002019
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002020 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2021 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2022 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2023 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002024 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002025 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002026 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002027 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002028 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002029 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002030
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002031 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002032 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002033 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002034
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002035 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2036 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2037 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2038 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002039 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002040 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002041 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002042 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002043 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002044 }
2045
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002046 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002047 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002048 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002049
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002050 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2051 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2052 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2053 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002054 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002055 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002056 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002057 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002058 }
2059 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002060
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002061 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2062 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002063 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002064 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002065 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002066 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002067 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002068
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002069 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2070 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002071 }
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002072 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002073 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002074
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002075 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2076 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002077 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002078 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002079
2080 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002081}
2082
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002083ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002084 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002085 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002086 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002087}
2088
2089/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2090/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002091bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002092 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2093 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2094 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002095 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2096 return false;
2097
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002098 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2099 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2100 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2101 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2102 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2103 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2104
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002105 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002106 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002107 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002108 if (isSizeof)
2109 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2110 return false;
2111 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002112
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002113 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002114 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002115 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2116 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002117 return false;
2118 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002119
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002120 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002121 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2122 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002123 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002124
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002125 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002126 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002127 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002128 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2129 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002130 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002131
Douglas Gregor9ba6af82010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002132 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2133 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2134 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2135 return true;
2136 }
2137
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002138 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002139}
2140
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002141bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2142 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2143 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002144
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002145 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002146 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2147 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002148
2149 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2150 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2151 return false;
2152
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002153 if (E->getBitField()) {
2154 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2155 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002156 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002157
2158 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2159 // bit-field.
2160 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002161 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002162 return false;
2163
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002164 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2165}
2166
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002167/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002168ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002169Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002170 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002171 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002172 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002173 return ExprError();
2174
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002175 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002176
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002177 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2178 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2179 return ExprError();
2180
2181 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002182 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002183 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2184 R.getEnd()));
2185}
2186
2187/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2188/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002189ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002190Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002191 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2192 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2193 bool isInvalid = false;
2194 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2195 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2196 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2197 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002198 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002199 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2200 isInvalid = true;
2201 } else {
2202 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2203 }
2204
2205 if (isInvalid)
2206 return ExprError();
2207
2208 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2209 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2210 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2211 R.getEnd()));
2212}
2213
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002214/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2215/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2216/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002217ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002218Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2219 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002220 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002221 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002222
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002223 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002224 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002225 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002226 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002227 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002228
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002229 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002230 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002231 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2232
2233 if (Result.isInvalid())
2234 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2235
2236 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002237}
2238
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002239QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002240 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2241 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002242
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002243 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002244 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002245 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002246
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002247 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2248 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2249 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002250
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002251 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002252 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2253 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002254 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002255}
2256
2257
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002258
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002259ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002260Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002261 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002262 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002263 switch (Kind) {
2264 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002265 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2266 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002267 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002268
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002269 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002270}
2271
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002272ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002273Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2274 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002275 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002276 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002277 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2278 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002279
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002280 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002281
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002282 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002283 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002284 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2285 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2286 }
2287
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002288 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002289 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002290 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2291 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2292 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002293 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002294 }
2295
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002296 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002297}
2298
2299
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002300ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002301Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2302 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2303 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2304 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002305
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002306 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002307 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2308 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2309 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002310
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002311 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002312
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002313 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002314 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002315 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002316 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002317 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2318 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002319 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2320 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2321 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2322 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002323 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002324 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2325 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002326 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002327 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002328 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002329 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2330 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002331 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002332 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002333 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002334 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2335 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2336 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002337 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002338 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002339 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2340 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2341 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2342 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002343 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002344 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002345 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002346
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002347 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2348 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002349 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2350 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002351 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002352 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2353 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2354 // force the promotion here.
2355 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2356 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002357 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002358 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002359 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2360
2361 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2362 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002363 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002364 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2365 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2366 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2367 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002368 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002369 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002370 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2371
2372 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2373 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002374 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002375 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002376 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2377 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002378 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002379 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002380 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002381 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2382 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002383
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002384 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002385 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2386 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002387 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2388
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002389 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002390 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2391 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002392 // incomplete types are not object types.
2393 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2394 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2395 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2396 return ExprError();
2397 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002398
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002399 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002400 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002401 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2402 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002403 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002404
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002405 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002406 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002407 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2408 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2409 return ExprError();
2410 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002411
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002412 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002413 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002414}
2415
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002416QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002417CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002418 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002419 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002420 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2421 // see FIXME there.
2422 //
2423 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2424 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002425 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002426
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002427 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002428 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002429
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002430 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002431 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2432 // to be selected.
2433 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002434
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002435 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2436 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002437 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002438
2439 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2440 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002441 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002442 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2443 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002444 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002445 do
2446 compStr++;
2447 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002448 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002449 do
2450 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002451 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002452 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002453
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002454 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002455 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2456 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002457 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002458 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002459 return QualType();
2460 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002461
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002462 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2463 // operates on.
2464 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002465 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002466
2467 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002468 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002469
2470 while (*compStr) {
2471 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2472 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2473 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2474 return QualType();
2475 }
2476 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002477 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002478
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002479 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002480 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002481 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002482 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002483 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002484 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002485 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002486 if (HexSwizzle)
2487 CompSize--;
2488
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002489 if (CompSize == 1)
2490 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002491
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002492 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002493 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002494 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2495 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2496 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2497 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002498 }
2499 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002500}
2501
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002502static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002503 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002504 const Selector &Sel,
2505 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002506
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002507 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002508 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002509 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002510 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002511
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002512 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2513 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002514 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002515 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002516 return D;
2517 }
2518 return 0;
2519}
2520
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002521static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002522 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002523 const Selector &Sel,
2524 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002525 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2526 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002527 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002528 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002529 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002530 GDecl = PD;
2531 break;
2532 }
2533 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002534 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002535 GDecl = OMD;
2536 break;
2537 }
2538 }
2539 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002540 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002541 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2542 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002543 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002544 if (GDecl)
2545 return GDecl;
2546 }
2547 }
2548 return GDecl;
2549}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002550
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002551ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002552Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002553 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002554 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2555 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002556 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002557 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002558 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2559 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2560 //
2561 // T* t;
2562 // t.f;
2563 //
2564 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2565 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2566 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2567 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002568 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002569 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2570 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002571 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002572 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002573 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002574 return ExprError();
2575 }
2576 }
2577
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002578 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2579 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002580 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002581
2582 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2583 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002584 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002585 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002586 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002587 SS.getRange(),
2588 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002589 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002590}
2591
2592/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2593/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2594/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2595static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2596 Expr *BaseExpr,
2597 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002598 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002599 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002600 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2601 // diagnostics.
2602 if (!BaseExpr)
2603 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002604
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002605 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2606 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002607}
2608
2609// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2610// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2611// type. The restriction here is:
2612//
2613// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2614// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2615// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2616//
2617// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2618// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2619// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2620// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2621bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2622 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002623 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002624 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002625 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2626 if (!BaseRT) {
2627 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2628 // dependent.
2629 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2630 return false;
2631 }
2632 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002633
2634 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002635 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2636 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002637 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002638 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002639
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002640 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002641 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2642 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2643 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002644
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002645 if (!DC->isRecord())
2646 continue;
2647
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002648 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002649 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002650
2651 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2652 return false;
2653 }
2654
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002655 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002656 return true;
2657}
2658
2659static bool
2660LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2661 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002662 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2663 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002664 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2665 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002666 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002667 << BaseRange))
2668 return true;
2669
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002670 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2671 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2672 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2673
2674 bool MOUS;
2675 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2676 return false;
2677 }
2678
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002679 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2680 if (SS.isSet()) {
2681 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2682 // nested-name-specifier.
2683 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2684
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002685 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002686 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2687 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2688 return true;
2689 }
2690
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002691 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002692
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002693 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2694 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2695 << DC << SS.getRange();
2696 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002697 }
2698 }
2699
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002700 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2701 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002702
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002703 if (!R.empty())
2704 return false;
2705
2706 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2707 // for typos.
2708 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002709 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002710 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002711 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2712 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2713 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002714 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2715 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002716 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2717 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2718 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002719 return false;
2720 } else {
2721 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002722 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002723 }
2724
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002725 return false;
2726}
2727
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002728ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002729Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002730 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002731 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002732 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002733 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002734 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002735 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2736 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002737 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002738 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2739 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002740 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002741
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002742 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002743
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002744 // Implicit member accesses.
2745 if (!Base) {
2746 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2747 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2748 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2749 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002750 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002751 return ExprError();
2752
2753 // Explicit member accesses.
2754 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002755 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002756 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002757 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002758
2759 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2760 Owned(Base);
2761 return ExprError();
2762 }
2763
2764 if (Result.get())
2765 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002766
2767 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2768 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002769 }
2770
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002771 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002772 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2773 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002774}
2775
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002776ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002777Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002778 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2779 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002780 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002781 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002782 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2783 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002784 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002785 if (IsArrow) {
2786 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2787 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2788 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002789 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002790
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002791 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002792 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2793 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2794 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002795
2796 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002797 return ExprError();
2798
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002799 if (R.empty()) {
2800 // Rederive where we looked up.
2801 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2802 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2803 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002804
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002805 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002806 << MemberName << DC
2807 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002808 return ExprError();
2809 }
2810
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002811 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2812 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2813 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2814 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2815 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2816 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2817 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2818 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2819 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2820 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002821 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002822 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002823 return ExprError();
2824
2825 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2826 // result.
2827 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002828 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002829 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002830 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002831 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002832
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002833 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2834 // pick a member.
2835 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2836
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002837 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2838 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2839 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002840 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2841 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002842 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002843 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002844 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002845
2846 return Owned(MemExpr);
2847 }
2848
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002849 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002850 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002851 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2852
2853 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2854
2855 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2856 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2857 // error cases.
2858 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2859 return ExprError();
2860
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002861 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2862 if (!BaseExpr) {
2863 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002864 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002865 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002866
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002867 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2868 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2869 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2870 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002871 }
2872
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002873 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2874 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2875 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2876 // explicitly qualified.
2877 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2878 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2879 }
2880
2881 // Check the use of this member.
2882 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2883 Owned(BaseExpr);
2884 return ExprError();
2885 }
2886
2887 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2888 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2889 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002890 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2891 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002892 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2893 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2894
2895 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2896 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2897 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2898 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2899 else {
2900 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2901 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2902 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2903
2904 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2905 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2906
2907 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2908 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2909 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2910 }
2911
2912 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002913 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002914 return ExprError();
2915 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002916 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2917 MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002918 }
2919
2920 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2921 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2922 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002923 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002924 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2925 }
2926
2927 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2928 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2929 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002930 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002931 MemberFn->getType()));
2932 }
2933
2934 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2935 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2936 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002937 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2938 Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002939 }
2940
2941 Owned(BaseExpr);
2942
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002943 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002944 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002945 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002946 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2947 else
2948 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2949 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002950
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002951 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2952 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002953 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002954 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002955}
2956
2957/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2958/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2959/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2960/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2961/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2962/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2963/// an ordinary member expression.
2964///
2965/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2966/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002967ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002968Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002969 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002970 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002971 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002972 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002973
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002974 // Perform default conversions.
2975 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002976
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002977 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002978 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2979
2980 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2981 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002982
2983 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002984 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002985 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2986 // call, and continue on.
2987 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2988 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2989 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2990 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2991 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002992 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2993 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002994 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2995 ->isRecordType()))) {
2996 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2997 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2998 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002999 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003000
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003001 ExprResult NewBase
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003002 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc,
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003003 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003004 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003005 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003006 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003007
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003008 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3009 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3010 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3011 }
3012 }
3013 }
3014
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003015 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3016 // use that.
3017 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003018 if (IsArrow) {
3019 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3020 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3021 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003022 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003023 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003024 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3025 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003026 }
3027 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003028 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3029 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3030 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3031 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003032 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003033 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003034 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003035
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003036 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3037 // use that.
3038 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3039 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3040 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3041 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3042 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003043 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003044 }
3045 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003046
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003047 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003048
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003049 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003050 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003051 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3052 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3053 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3054 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3055 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3056 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3057 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3058 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3059 // Check the use of this method.
3060 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3061 return ExprError();
3062 }
3063 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3064 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3065 Selector SetterSel =
3066 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3067 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3068 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3069 if (!Setter) {
3070 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3071 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003072 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003073 }
3074 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3075 if (!Setter)
3076 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003077
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003078 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3079 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003080
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003081 if (Getter || Setter) {
3082 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003083
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003084 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003085 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003086 else
3087 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3088 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3089 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003090 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003091 PType,
3092 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3093 }
3094 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3095 << MemberName << BaseType);
3096 }
3097 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003098
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003099 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3100 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3101 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003102 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003103 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003104
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003105 if (IsArrow) {
3106 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003107 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003108 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3109 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003110 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3111 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3112 // struct MyRecord foo;
3113 // foo->bar
3114 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3115 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3116 // by now.
3117 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3118 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003119 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003120 IsArrow = false;
3121 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003122 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3123 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3124 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003125 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003126 } else {
3127 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3128 // type *foo;
3129 // foo.bar
3130 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3131 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3132 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3133 // the appropriate pointer type
3134 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3135 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3136 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3137 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3138 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003139 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003140 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3141 IsArrow = true;
3142 }
3143 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003144 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003145
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003146 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003147 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003148 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003149 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003150 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003151 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003152 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003153
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003154 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3155 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003156 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003157 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003158 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003159 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3160 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3161 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3162 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003163 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3164
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003165 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003166 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003167
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003168 if (!IV) {
3169 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3170 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3171 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003172 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003173 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003174 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003175 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3176 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003177 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3178 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003179 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003180 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003181 } else {
3182 Res.clear();
3183 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003184 }
3185 }
3186
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003187 if (IV) {
3188 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3189 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3190 // error cases.
3191 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3192 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003193
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003194 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3195 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3196 return ExprError();
3197 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3198 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3199 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3200 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3201 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3202 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3203 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3204 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3205 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3206 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3207 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3208 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003209 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003210 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003211 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3212 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003213 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003214 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3215 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003216
3217 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3218 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003219 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003220 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003221 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003222 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3223 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003224 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003225 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003226 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003227
3228 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3229 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003230 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003231 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003232 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003233 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003234 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003235 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003236 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003237 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003238 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3239 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003240 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003241 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003242
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003243 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003244 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003245 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3246 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3247 // Check the use of this declaration
3248 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3249 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003250
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003251 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3252 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3253 }
3254 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3255 // Check the use of this method.
3256 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3257 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003258
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003259 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003260 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor04badcf2010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003261 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3262 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003263 }
3264 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003265
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003266 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003267 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003268 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003269
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003270 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3271 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003272 if (!IsArrow)
3273 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3274 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003275 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003276
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003277 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003278 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003279 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3280 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003281 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003282 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003283 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003284
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003285 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003286 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003287 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003288 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3289 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003290 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003291 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003292 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003293 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003294
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003295 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3296 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3297
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003298 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003299}
3300
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003301/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3302/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3303/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3304/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3305/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3306///
3307/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3308/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3309/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3310/// only be called
3311/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3312/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3313/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003314ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003315 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3316 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003317 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003318 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003319 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003320 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3321 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3322 return ExprError();
3323
3324 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3325
3326 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003327 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003328 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3329 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003330 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003331
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003332 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003333 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3334
3335 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3336 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3337 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3338
3339 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003340 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003341 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3342 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003343
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003344 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3345 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003346 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003347 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3348 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003349 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003350 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003351 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003352 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3353 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003354
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003355 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3356 Owned(Base);
3357 return ExprError();
3358 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003359
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003360 if (Result.get()) {
3361 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3362 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3363 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3364 // call now.
3365 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3366 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003367 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003368
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003369 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003370 }
3371
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003372 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003373 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3374 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003375 }
3376
3377 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003378}
3379
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003380ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003381 FunctionDecl *FD,
3382 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3383 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3384 Diag (CallLoc,
3385 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3386 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003387 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003388 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3389 } else {
3390 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3391 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3392
3393 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor525f96c2010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003394 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3395 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003396
Douglas Gregor24bae922010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003397 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3398 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3399 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3400 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003401
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003402 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003403 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003404 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003405
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003406 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3407 InitializedEntity Entity
3408 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3409 InitializationKind Kind
3410 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3411 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3412 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3413
3414 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003415 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003416 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003417 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003418 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003419
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003420 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003421 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003422 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003423 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003424
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003425 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3426 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3427 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003428 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3429 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson337cba42009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003430 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3431 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003432 }
3433
3434 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003435 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003436}
3437
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003438/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3439/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3440/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3441/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3442/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3443/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003444bool
3445Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003446 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003447 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003448 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3449 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003450 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003451 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3452 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003453 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003454
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003455 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3456 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3457 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3458 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3459 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003460 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003461 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003462 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003463 }
3464
3465 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3466 // them.
3467 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3468 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3469 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3470 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003471 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003472 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003473 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3474 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3475 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003476 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003477 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003478 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003479 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003480 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003481 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003482 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3483 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3484 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3485 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3486 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003487 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003488 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003489 if (Invalid)
3490 return true;
3491 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3492 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3493 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003494
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003495 return false;
3496}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003497
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003498bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3499 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3500 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3501 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3502 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3503 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003504 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003505 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3506 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3507 bool Invalid = false;
3508 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3509 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3510 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3511 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003512 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003513 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003514 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003515
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003516 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003517 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3518 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003519
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003520 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3521 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003522 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003523 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003524 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003525
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003526 // Pass the argument
3527 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3528 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3529 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003530
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003531
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003532 InitializedEntity Entity =
3533 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3534 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003535 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003536 SourceLocation(),
3537 Owned(Arg));
3538 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3539 return true;
3540
3541 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003542 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003543 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003544
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003545 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003546 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003547 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3548 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003549
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003550 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003551 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003552 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003553 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003554
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003555 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003556 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003557 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003558 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003559 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003560 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003561 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003562 }
3563 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003564 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003565}
3566
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003567/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003568/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3569/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003570ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003571Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003572 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003573 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003574 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003575
3576 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003577 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003578 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3579 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003580
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003581 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003582
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003583 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003584 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3585 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3586 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3587 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3588 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003589 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003590 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3591 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003592
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003593 NumArgs = 0;
3594 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003595
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003596 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3597 RParenLoc));
3598 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003599
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003600 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003601 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003602 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3603 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003604 bool Dependent = false;
3605 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3606 Dependent = true;
3607 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3608 Dependent = true;
3609
3610 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003611 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003612 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3613
3614 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3615 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3616 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3617 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3618
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003619 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3620
3621 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3622 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3623 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3624 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3625 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3626 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3627 // method template.
3628 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003629 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3630 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003631 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003632
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003633 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3634 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003635 }
3636
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003637 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003638 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003639 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003640 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003641 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3642 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003643 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003644
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003645 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003646 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003647 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3648 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003649 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3650 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003651 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003652
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003653 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3654 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3655 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3656 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003657
3658 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3659 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003660 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003661 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003662
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003663 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003664 RParenLoc))
3665 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003666
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003667 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003668 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003669 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003670 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3671 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003672 }
3673 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003674 }
3675
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003676 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003677 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003678 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003679
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003680 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003681 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3682 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003683 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003684 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003685 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003686
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003687 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3688 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3689 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3690
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003691 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3692}
3693
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003694/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3695/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003696/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3697/// block-pointer type.
3698///
3699/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003700ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003701Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3702 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3703 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3704 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3705 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3706
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003707 // Promote the function operand.
3708 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3709
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003710 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3711 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003712 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3713 Args, NumArgs,
3714 Context.BoolTy,
3715 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003716
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003717 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3718 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3719 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3720 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003721 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003722 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003723 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3724 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003725 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003726 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003727 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003728 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003729 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003730 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003731 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3732 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3733
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003734 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003735 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003736 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003737 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003738 return ExprError();
3739
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003740 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003741 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003742
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003743 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003744 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003745 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003746 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003747 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003748 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003749
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003750 if (FDecl) {
3751 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3752 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3753 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003754 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003755 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003756 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003757 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3758 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3759 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3760 }
3761 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003762 }
3763
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003764 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003765 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3766 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3767 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003768 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3769 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003770 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3771 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003772 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003773 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003774 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003775 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003776
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003777 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3778 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003779 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3780 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003781
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003782 // Check for sentinels
3783 if (NDecl)
3784 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003785
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003786 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003787 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003788 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003789 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003790
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003791 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003792 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003793 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003794 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003795 return ExprError();
3796 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003797
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003798 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003799}
3800
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003801ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003802Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003803 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003804 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003805 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003806 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003807
3808 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3809 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3810 if (!TInfo)
3811 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3812
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003813 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003814}
3815
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003816ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003817Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003818 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003819 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003820
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003821 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003822 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003823 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3824 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003825 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3826 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003827 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003828 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003829 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003830 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003831
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003832 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003833 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003834 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003835 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003836 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003837 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003838 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003839 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003840 &literalType);
3841 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003842 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003843 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003844
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003845 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003846 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003847 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003848 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003849 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003850
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003851 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003852 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003853}
3854
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003855ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003856Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003857 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3858 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003859 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003860
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003861 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003862 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003863
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003864 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3865 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003866 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003867 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003868}
3869
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003870static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003871 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003872 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003873 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003874
3875 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3876 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003877 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003878 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3879 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003880 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003881 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003882 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003883
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003884 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3885 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003886 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003887 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003888 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003889 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003890 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003891 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003892
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003893 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3894 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003895 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003896 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003897 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003898 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003899
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003900 // FIXME: Assert here.
3901 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003902 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003903}
3904
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003905/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003906bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003907 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003908 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003909 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003910 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003911 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3912 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003913
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003914 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003915
3916 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3917 // type needs to be scalar.
3918 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3919 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003920 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003921 return false;
3922 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003923
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003924 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3925 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3926 return true;
3927
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003928 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003929 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003930 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3931 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003932 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003933 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3934 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003935 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003936 return false;
3937 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003938
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003939 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003940 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003941 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003942 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003943 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003944 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003945 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003946 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003947 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3948 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3949 break;
3950 }
3951 }
3952 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3953 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3954 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003955 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003956 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003957 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003958
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003959 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3960 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3961 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3962 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003963
3964 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003965 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003966 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3967 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003968 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003969 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003970
3971 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003972 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003973
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003974 if (castType->isVectorType())
3975 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3976 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3977 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3978
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003979 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3980 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003981
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003982 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003983 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003984 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003985 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003986 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3987 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3988 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3989 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003990 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003991 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3992 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3993 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003994 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003995
3996 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00003997
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003998 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00003999 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4000
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004001 return false;
4002}
4003
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004004bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004005 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004006 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004007
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004008 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004009 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004010 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004011 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004012 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004013 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004014 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004015 } else
4016 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004017 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004018 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004019
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004020 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004021 return false;
4022}
4023
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004024bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004025 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004026 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004027
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004028 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004029
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004030 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4031 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004032 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4033 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4034 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4035 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004036 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004037 return false;
4038 }
4039
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004040 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004041 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4042 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004043 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4044 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4045 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4046 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004047
4048 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4049 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4050 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004051
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004052 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004053 return false;
4054}
4055
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004056ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004057Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004058 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4059 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004060 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004061
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004062 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4063 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4064 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004065 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004066
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004067 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4068 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004069 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004070 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004071
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004072 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004073}
4074
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004075ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004076Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004077 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004078 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004079 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004080 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004081 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004082 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004083
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004084 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004085 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004086 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4087 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004088}
4089
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004090/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4091/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004092ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004093Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004094 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4095 if (!E)
4096 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004097
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004098 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004099
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004100 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004101 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4102 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004103
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004104 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4105
4106 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004107}
4108
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004109ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004110Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004111 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004112 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004113 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004114 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004115 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004116
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004117 // Check for an altivec literal,
4118 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004119 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4120 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4121 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4122 return ExprError();
4123 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004124 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4125 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4126 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4127 }
4128 else
4129 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4130 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004131
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004132 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4133 // then handle it as such.
4134 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004135 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4136 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4137 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4138
4139 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4140 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004141 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4142 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004143 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4144 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004145 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004146 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004147 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004148 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004149 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004150 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4151 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004152 }
4153}
4154
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004155ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004156 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004157 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004158 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004159 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4160 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004161 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4162 Expr *expr;
4163 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4164 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4165 else
4166 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004167 return Owned(expr);
4168}
4169
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004170/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4171/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004172/// C99 6.5.15
4173QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4174 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004175 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4176 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4177 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4178
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004179 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4180 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4181 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4182 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4183 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4184 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004185
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004186 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004187 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4188 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4189 << CondTy;
4190 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004191 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004192
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004193 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004194 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4195 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004196
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004197 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4198 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004199 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4200 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4201 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004202 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004203
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004204 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4205 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004206 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4207 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004208 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004209 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004210 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004211 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004212 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004213 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004214
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004215 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004216 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004217 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4218 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4219 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4220 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4221 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4222 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4223 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004224 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4225 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004226 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004227 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004228 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4229 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004230 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004231 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004232 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004233 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004234 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004235 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004236 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004237 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004238 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004239 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004240 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004241
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004242 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4243 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4244 QuestionLoc);
4245 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4246 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004247
4248
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004249 // Handle block pointer types.
4250 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4251 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4252 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4253 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004254 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4255 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004256 return destType;
4257 }
4258 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004259 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004260 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004261 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004262 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4263 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4264 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004265 return LHSTy;
4266 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004267 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004268 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4269 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004270
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004271 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4272 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004273 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004274 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004275 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4276 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4277 // to get a consistent AST.
4278 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004279 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4280 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004281 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004282 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004283 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004284 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4285 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004286 return LHSTy;
4287 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004288
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004289 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4290 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4291 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004292 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4293 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004294
4295 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4296 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4297 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004298 QualType destPointee
4299 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004300 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004301 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004302 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004303 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004304 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004305 return destType;
4306 }
4307 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004308 QualType destPointee
4309 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004310 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004311 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004312 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004313 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004314 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004315 return destType;
4316 }
4317
4318 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4319 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4320 return LHSTy;
4321 }
4322 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4323 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4324 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4325 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4326 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4327 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4328 // to get a consistent AST.
4329 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004330 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4331 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004332 return incompatTy;
4333 }
4334 // The pointer types are compatible.
4335 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4336 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4337 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4338 // type.
4339 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4340 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004341 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4342 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004343 return LHSTy;
4344 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004345
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004346 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4347 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4348 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4349 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004350 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004351 return RHSTy;
4352 }
4353 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4354 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4355 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004356 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004357 return LHSTy;
4358 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004359
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004360 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004361 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4362 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004363 return QualType();
4364}
4365
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004366/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4367/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4368QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4369 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4370 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4371 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004372
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004373 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4374 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4375 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4376 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4377 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004378 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004379 return LHSTy;
4380 }
4381 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4382 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004383 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004384 return RHSTy;
4385 }
4386 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4387 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4388 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004389 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004390 return LHSTy;
4391 }
4392 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4393 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004394 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004395 return RHSTy;
4396 }
4397 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4398 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4399 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004400 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004401 return LHSTy;
4402 }
4403 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4404 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004405 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004406 return RHSTy;
4407 }
4408 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4409 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004410
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004411 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4412 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4413 return LHSTy;
4414 }
4415 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4416 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4417 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004418
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004419 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4420 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4421 // type. This allows
4422 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4423 // where B is a subclass of A.
4424 //
4425 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4426 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4427 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4428 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004429
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004430 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4431 // It could return the composite type.
4432 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4433 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4434 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4435 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4436 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4437 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4438 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4439 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4440 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4441 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4442 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4443 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4444 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4445 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004446 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004447 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4448 ;
4449 else {
4450 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4451 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4452 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4453 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004454 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4455 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004456 return incompatTy;
4457 }
4458 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004459 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4460 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004461 return compositeType;
4462 }
4463 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4464 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4465 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4466 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4467 QualType destPointee
4468 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4469 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4470 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004471 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004472 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004473 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004474 return destType;
4475 }
4476 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4477 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4478 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4479 QualType destPointee
4480 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4481 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4482 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004483 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004484 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004485 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004486 return destType;
4487 }
4488 return QualType();
4489}
4490
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004491/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004492/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004493ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004494 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004495 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4496 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004497 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4498 // was the condition.
4499 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4500 if (isLHSNull)
4501 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004502
4503 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattner26824902007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004504 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004505 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004506 return ExprError();
4507
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004508 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004509 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004510 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004511}
4512
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004513// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004514// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004515// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4516// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4517// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004518Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004519Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4520 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004521
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004522 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4523 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4524 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4525 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4526 return Compatible;
4527 }
4528
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004529 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004530 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4531 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004532
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004533 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004534 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4535 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004536
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004537 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004538
4539 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4540 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4541 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004542 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004543 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004544 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004545
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004546 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4547 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004548 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004549 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004550 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004551 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004552
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004553 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004554 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4555 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004556 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004557
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004558 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004559 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004560 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004561
4562 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004563 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4564 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004565 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004566 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004567 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004568 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4569 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4570 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4571 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4572 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4573 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004574 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004575 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004576 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004577 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004578
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004579 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004580 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004581 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004582 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004583
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004584 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4585 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4586 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4587 // warning can be disabled.
4588 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4589 return ConvTy;
4590 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4591 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004592
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004593 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4594 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4595 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4596 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4597 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4598 do {
4599 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4600 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004601
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004602 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4603 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4604 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004605
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004606 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004607 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004608 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004609
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004610 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004611 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004612 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004613 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004614}
4615
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004616/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4617/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4618/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4619// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004620Sema::AssignConvertType
4621Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004622 QualType rhsType) {
4623 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004624
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004625 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004626 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4627 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004628
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004629 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4630 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4631 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004632
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004633 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004634
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004635 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004636 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004637 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004638
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004639 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4640 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4641 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4642 }
4643 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004644 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004645 return ConvTy;
4646}
4647
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004648/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4649/// for assignment compatibility.
4650Sema::AssignConvertType
4651Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004652 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4653 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004654 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4655 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004656 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004657 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004658 }
4659 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4660 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004661 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4662 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004663 return IncompatiblePointer;
4664 return Compatible;
4665 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004666 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004667 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004668 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004669 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4670 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4671 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4672 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4673 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4674 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004675
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004676 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4677 return Compatible;
4678 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4679 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004680 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004681}
4682
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004683/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4684/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004685/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4686///
4687/// int a, *pint;
4688/// short *pshort;
4689/// struct foo *pfoo;
4690///
4691/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4692/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4693/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4694/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4695///
4696/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004697/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004698///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004699Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004700Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004701 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4702 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004703 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4704 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004705
4706 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004707 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004708
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004709 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4710 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4711 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4712 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4713 return Compatible;
4714 }
4715
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004716 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4717 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4718 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4719 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4720 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4721 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4722 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004723 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004724 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004725 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004726 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004727 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004728 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4729 // to the same ExtVector type.
4730 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4731 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4732 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004733 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004734 return Compatible;
4735 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004736
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004737 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004738 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4739 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4740 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4741 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4742 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4743 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004744 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004745
4746 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4747 // vector type and vice versa
4748 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4749 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004750 }
4751 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004752 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004753
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004754 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4755 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004756 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004757
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004758 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004759 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004760 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004761
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004762 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004763 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004764
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004765 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004766 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004767 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4768 return Compatible;
4769 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004770 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004771 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4772 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004773 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004774
4775 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004776 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004777 return Compatible;
4778 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004779 return Incompatible;
4780 }
4781
4782 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4783 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004784 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004785
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004786 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004787 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004788 return Compatible;
4789
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004790 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4791 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004792
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004793 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004794 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004795 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004796 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004797 return Incompatible;
4798 }
4799
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004800 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4801 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4802 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004803
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004804 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004805 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004806 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4807 return Compatible;
4808 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004809 }
4810 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004811 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004812 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004813 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004814 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4815 return Compatible;
4816 }
4817 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4818 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4819 return Compatible;
4820 return Incompatible;
4821 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004822 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004823 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004824 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4825 return Compatible;
4826
4827 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004828 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004829
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004830 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004831 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004832
4833 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004834 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004835 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004836 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004837 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004838 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4839 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4840 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4841 return Compatible;
4842
4843 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4844 return PointerToInt;
4845
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004846 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004847 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004848 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4849 return Compatible;
4850 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004851 }
4852 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004853 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004854 return Compatible;
4855 return Incompatible;
4856 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004857
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004858 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004859 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004860 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004861 }
4862 return Incompatible;
4863}
4864
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004865/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4866/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004867static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004868 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4869 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4870 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004871 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004872 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004873 SourceLocation());
4874 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4875 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4876
4877 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4878 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004879 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004880 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004881 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004882}
4883
4884Sema::AssignConvertType
4885Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4886 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4887
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004888 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004889 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4890 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004891 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004892 return Incompatible;
4893
4894 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4895 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4896 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4897 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004898 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4899 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004900 it != itend; ++it) {
4901 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4902 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4903 // 1) void pointer
4904 // 2) null pointer constant
4905 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004906 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004907 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004908 InitField = *it;
4909 break;
4910 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004911
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004912 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004913 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004914 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004915 InitField = *it;
4916 break;
4917 }
4918 }
4919
4920 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4921 == Compatible) {
4922 InitField = *it;
4923 break;
4924 }
4925 }
4926
4927 if (!InitField)
4928 return Incompatible;
4929
4930 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4931 return Compatible;
4932}
4933
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004934Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004935Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004936 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4937 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4938 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4939 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4940 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004941 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004942 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004943 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004944 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004945 }
4946
4947 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4948 // structures.
4949 }
4950
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004951 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4952 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004953 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4954 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004955 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004956 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004957 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004958 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004959 return Compatible;
4960 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004961
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004962 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004963 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004964 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00004965 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004966 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004967 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004968 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004969 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004970
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004971 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4972 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004973
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004974 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4975 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004976 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4977 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4978 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4979 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004980 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004981 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004982 CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004983 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004984}
4985
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004986QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004987 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004988 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004989 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004990 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004991}
4992
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004993QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004994 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004995 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004996 QualType lhsType =
4997 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4998 QualType rhsType =
4999 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005000
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005001 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005002 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005003 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005004
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005005 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5006 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005007 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
5008 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005009 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5010 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005011 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005012 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005013 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005014 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005015 return lhsType;
5016 }
5017
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005018 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005019 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005020 }
5021 }
5022 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005023
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005024 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5025 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5026 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005027 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005028 return rhsType;
5029 }
5030
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005031 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5032 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5033 bool swapped = false;
5034 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5035 swapped = true;
5036 std::swap(rex, lex);
5037 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5038 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005039
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005040 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005041 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005042 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005043 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005044 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005045 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005046 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5047 return lhsType;
5048 }
5049 }
5050 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5051 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5052 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005053 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005054 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5055 return lhsType;
5056 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005057 }
5058 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005059
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005060 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005061 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005062 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005063 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005064 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005065}
5066
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005067QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5068 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005069 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005070 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005071
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005072 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005073
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005074 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5075 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5076 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005077
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005078 // Check for division by zero.
5079 if (isDiv &&
5080 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005081 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005082 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005083
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005084 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005085}
5086
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005087QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005088 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005089 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005090 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5091 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005092 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5093 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5094 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005095
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005096 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005097
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005098 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5099 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005100
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005101 // Check for remainder by zero.
5102 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005103 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5104 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005105
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005106 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005107}
5108
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005109QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005110 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005111 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5112 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5113 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5114 return compType;
5115 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005116
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005117 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005118
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005119 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005120 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5121 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5122 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005123 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005124 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005125
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005126 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5127 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005128 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005129 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5130
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005131 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005132
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005133 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005134 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005135
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005136 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5137 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005138 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5139 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005140 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005141 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005142 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005143
5144 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5145 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5146 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005147 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005148 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5149 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5150 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5151 return QualType();
5152 }
5153
5154 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5155 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5156 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005157 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005158 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005159 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005160 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005161 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5162 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005163 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5164 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005165 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005166 return QualType();
5167 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005168 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005169 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005170 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5171 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5172 return QualType();
5173 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005174
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005175 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005176 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5177 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5178 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5179 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5180 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005181 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005182 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5183 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005184 return PExp->getType();
5185 }
5186 }
5187
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005188 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005189}
5190
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005191// C99 6.5.6
5192QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005193 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5194 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5195 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5196 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5197 return compType;
5198 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005199
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005200 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005201
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005202 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005203
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005204 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005205 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5206 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005207 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005208 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005209 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005210
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005211 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005212 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005213 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005214
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005215 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005216
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005217 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5218 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5219 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5220 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5221 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5222 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5223 return QualType();
5224 }
5225
5226 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5227 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5228 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5229 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5230 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005231 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005232 return QualType();
5233 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005234
5235 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5236 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5237 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005238 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005239 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005240 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005241 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005242 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005243
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005244 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005245 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005246 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5247 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5248 return QualType();
5249 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005250
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005251 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005252 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5253 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5254 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5255 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5256 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5257 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005258 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005259 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5260
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005261 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005262 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005263 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005264
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005265 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005266 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005267 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005268
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005269 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5270 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5271 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5272 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5273 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5274 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5275 return QualType();
5276 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005277
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005278 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5279 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5280 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5281 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005282 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005283 return QualType();
5284 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005285
5286 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5287 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5288 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5289 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5290 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005291 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5292 << rex->getSourceRange()
5293 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005294 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005295
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005296 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5297 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5298 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5299 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5300 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5301 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5302 return QualType();
5303 }
5304 } else {
5305 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5306 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5307 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5308 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5309 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5310 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5311 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5312 return QualType();
5313 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005314 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005315
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005316 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5317 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5318 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5319 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5320 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005321 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005322 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005323
5324 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005325 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5326 }
5327 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005328
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005329 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005330}
5331
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005332// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005333QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005334 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005335 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005336 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5337 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005338 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005339
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005340 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5341 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5342 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5343
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005344 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5345 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005346 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5347 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5348 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5349 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5350 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005351 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005352 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005353 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005354
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005355 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005356
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005357 // Sanity-check shift operands
5358 llvm::APSInt Right;
5359 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005360 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5361 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005362 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005363 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5364 else {
5365 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5366 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5367 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5368 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5369 }
5370 }
5371
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005372 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005373 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005374}
5375
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005376static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5377 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5378 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5379 return true;
5380 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5381 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5382 }
5383 return false;
5384}
5385
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005386// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005387QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005388 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005389 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005390
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005391 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005392 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005393 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005394
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005395 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5396 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005397
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005398 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5399 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005400 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5401 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5402 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005403 //
5404 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5405 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5406 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5407 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5408 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5409 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005410 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5411 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005412 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005413 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005414 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005415 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005416 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5417 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005418 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5419 || Opc == BO_LE
5420 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005421 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5422 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5423 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5424 // what is it always going to eval to?
5425 char always_evals_to;
5426 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005427 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005428 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5429 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005430 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005431 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5432 break;
5433 default:
5434 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5435 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5436 break;
5437 }
5438 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5439 << 1 // array
5440 << always_evals_to);
5441 }
5442 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005443 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005444
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005445 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5446 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5447 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5448 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005449
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005450 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5451 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005452 Expr *literalString = 0;
5453 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005454 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005455 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005456 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005457 literalString = lex;
5458 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005459 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5460 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005461 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005462 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005463 literalString = rex;
5464 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5465 }
5466
5467 if (literalString) {
5468 std::string resultComparison;
5469 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005470 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5471 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5472 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5473 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5474 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5475 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005476 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5477 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005478
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005479 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5480 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5481 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005482 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005483 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005484 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005485
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005486 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5487 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5488 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5489 else {
5490 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5491 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5492 }
5493
5494 lType = lex->getType();
5495 rType = rex->getType();
5496
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005497 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005498 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005499
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005500 if (isRelational) {
5501 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005502 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005503 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005504 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005505 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005506 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005507
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005508 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005509 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005510 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005511
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005512 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005513 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005514 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005515 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005516
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005517 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5518 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005519 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005520 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005521 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005522 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005523 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005524
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005525 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005526 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5527 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005528 if (!isRelational &&
5529 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5530 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5531 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005532 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5533 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005534 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5535 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005536 Diag(Loc,
5537 isSFINAEContext()?
5538 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5539 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005540 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005541
5542 if (isSFINAEContext())
5543 return QualType();
5544
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005545 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005546 return ResultTy;
5547 }
5548 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005549 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5550 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5551 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5552 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5553 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5554 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005555 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005556 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005557 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005558 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005559 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005560 if (T.isNull()) {
5561 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5562 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5563 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005564 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005565 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005566 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005567 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005568 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005569 }
5570
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005571 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5572 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005573 return ResultTy;
5574 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005575 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5576 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5577 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5578 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5579 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5580 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5581 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5582 }
5583 } else if (!isRelational &&
5584 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5585 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5586 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5587 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5588 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5589 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5590 }
5591 } else {
5592 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005593 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005594 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005595 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005596 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005597 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005598 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005599 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005600
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005601 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005602 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005603 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005604 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005605 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5606 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005607 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5608 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005609 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5610 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005611 return ResultTy;
5612 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005613 if (LHSIsNull &&
5614 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5615 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005616 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5617 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005618 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5619 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005620 return ResultTy;
5621 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005622
5623 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005624 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005625 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5626 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005627 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5628 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5629 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5630 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5631 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5632 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5633 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5634 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005635 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005636 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005637 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005638 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005639 if (T.isNull()) {
5640 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005641 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005642 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005643 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005644 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005645 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005646 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005647 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005648 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005649
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005650 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5651 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005652 return ResultTy;
5653 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005654
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005655 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005656 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5657 return ResultTy;
5658 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005659
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005660 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005661 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005662 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5663 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005664
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005665 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005666 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005667 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005668 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005669 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005670 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005671 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005672 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005673 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005674 if (!isRelational
5675 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5676 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005677 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005678 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005679 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005680 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005681 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5682 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5683 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005684 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005685 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005686 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005687 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005688
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005689 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005690 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005691 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5692 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005693 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005694 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005695 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005696 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005697
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005698 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5699 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005700 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005701 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005702 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005703 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005704 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005705 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005706 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005707 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005708 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5709 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005710 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005711 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005712 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005713 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005714 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5715 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005716 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005717 bool isError = false;
5718 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5719 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5720 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005721 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005722 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005723 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005724 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5725 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5726 isError = true;
5727 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005728 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005729
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005730 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005731 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005732 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005733 if (isError)
5734 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005735 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005736
5737 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005738 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005739 else
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005740 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005741 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005742 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005743
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005744 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005745 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5746 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005747 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005748 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005749 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005750 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5751 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005752 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005753 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005754 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005755 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005756}
5757
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005758/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005759/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005760/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5761/// types.
5762QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005763 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005764 bool isRelational) {
5765 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5766 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005767 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005768 if (vType.isNull())
5769 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005770
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005771 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5772 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005773
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005774 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5775 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5776 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005777 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005778 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5779 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5780 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005781 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5782 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5783 << 0 // self-
5784 << 2 // "a constant"
5785 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005786 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005787
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005788 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005789 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5790 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005791 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005792 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005793
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005794 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5795 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5796 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005797 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005798 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005799
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005800 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005801 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005802 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005803 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005804 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005805 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5806
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005807 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005808 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005809 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5810}
5811
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005812inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005813 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005814 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5815 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5816 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5817 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5818
5819 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5820 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005821
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005822 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005823
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005824 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005825 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005826 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005827}
5828
5829inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005830 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5831
5832 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5833 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5834 // is a constant.
5835 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005836 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005837 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005838 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5839 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5840 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5841 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5842 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5843 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5844 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5845 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5846 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005847 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5848 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005849 }
5850 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005851
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005852 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5853 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5854 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005855
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005856 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5857 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005858
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005859 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005860 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005861
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005862 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5863 // non-overloadable operands.
5864
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005865 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5866 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005867 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5868 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5869 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005870 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005871
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005872 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5873 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5874 // The result is a bool.
5875 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005876}
5877
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005878/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5879/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5880/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5881///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005882static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005883 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5884 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5885 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5886 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005887 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005888 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5889 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5890 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5891 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005892 }
5893 }
5894 return false;
5895}
5896
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005897/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5898/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5899static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005900 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005901 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005902 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005903 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5904 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005905 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5906 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005907
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005908 unsigned Diag = 0;
5909 bool NeedType = false;
5910 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005911 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005912 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005913 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5914 NeedType = true;
5915 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005916 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005917 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5918 NeedType = true;
5919 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005920 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005921 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5922 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005923 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5924 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005925 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005926 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5927 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005928 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5929 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005930 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5931 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005932 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005933 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005934 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005935 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005936 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5937 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005938 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005939 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5940 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005941 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5942 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5943 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005944 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5945 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5946 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005947 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5948 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5949 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005950 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005951
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005952 SourceRange Assign;
5953 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5954 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005955 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005956 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005957 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005958 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005959 return true;
5960}
5961
5962
5963
5964// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005965QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5966 SourceLocation Loc,
5967 QualType CompoundType) {
5968 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5969 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005970 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005971
5972 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5973 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005974 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005975 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005976 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005977 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005978 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5979 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5980 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5981 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5982 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5983 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5984 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5985 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5986 }
5987 }
5988
5989 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005990 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5991 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5992 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005993 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005994 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005995 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005996 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005997
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005998 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5999 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6000 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006001 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006002 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6003 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6004 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006005 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6006 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006007 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006008 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006009 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6010 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6011 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006012 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6013 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006014 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006015 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006016 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006017 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006018 }
6019 } else {
6020 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006021 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006022 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006023
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006024 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006025 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006026 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006027
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006028
6029 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6030 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6031 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6032 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6033 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6034 // check.
6035 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006036 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006037 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6038 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6039 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6040 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6041 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6042 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6043 }
6044
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006045 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6046 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006047 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006048 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6049 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006050 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006051 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006052 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006053}
6054
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006055// C99 6.5.17
6056QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006057 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6058
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006059 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006060 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6061 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6062 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006063
6064 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6065 // incomplete in C++).
6066
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006067 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006068}
6069
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006070/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6071/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006072QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006073 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006074 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6075 return Context.DependentTy;
6076
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006077 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6078 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006079
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006080 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6081 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6082 if (!isInc) {
6083 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6084 return QualType();
6085 }
6086 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6087 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6088 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006089 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006090 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6091 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006092
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006093 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006094 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006095 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6096 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6097 << Op->getSourceRange();
6098 return QualType();
6099 }
6100
6101 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006102 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006103 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006104 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6105 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6106 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6107 return QualType();
6108 }
6109
6110 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006111 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006112 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006113 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006114 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006115 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006116 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006117 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006118 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006119 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6120 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6121 return QualType();
6122 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006123 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006124 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6125 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006126 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006127 } else {
6128 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006129 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006130 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006131 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006132 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006133 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006134 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006135 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006136 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6137 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6138 // operand.
6139 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6140 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006141}
6142
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006143/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006144/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006145/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6146/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6147/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6148/// - &(x) => x
6149/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6150/// - &s.xx => s
6151/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6152/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6153/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6154/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006155static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006156 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006157 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006158 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006159 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006160 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6161 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6162 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006163 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006164 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006165 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006166 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006167 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006168 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6169 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006170 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6171 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6172 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6173 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6174 }
6175 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006176 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006177 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6178 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006179
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006180 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006181 case UO_Real:
6182 case UO_Imag:
6183 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006184 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6185 default:
6186 return 0;
6187 }
6188 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006189 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006190 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006191 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006192 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6193 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006194 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006195 default:
6196 return 0;
6197 }
6198}
6199
6200/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006201/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006202/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006203/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006204/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006205/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006206/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006207QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006208 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6209 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6210
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006211 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6212 return Context.DependentTy;
6213
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006214 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6215 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6216 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006217 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006218 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6219 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6220 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6221 }
6222 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6223 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6224 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006225 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006226 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006227
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006228 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6229 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6230 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6231 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6232 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6233 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6234 // branch of the if, below.
6235 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6236 << dcl;
6237 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6238
6239 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6240 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6241 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6242 .getTypePtr());
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006243 }
6244
6245 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006246 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6247 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6248 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6249 if (isSFINAEContext())
6250 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerc721ae82010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006251 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op))
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006252 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Chris Lattnerc721ae82010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006253 else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006254 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006255 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006256 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006257 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006258 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6259 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006260 return QualType();
6261 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006262 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006263 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6264 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6265 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006266 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006267 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006268 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006269 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006270 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006271 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006272 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6273 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6274 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6275 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6276 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006277 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6278 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006279 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6280 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Eli Friedmanfb3bb312010-08-24 05:23:20 +00006281 } else if (isa<OverloadExpr>(op)) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006282 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006283 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006284 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006285 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6286 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006287 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6288 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
6289 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register &&
6290 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006291 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6292 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006293 return QualType();
6294 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006295 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006296 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006297 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006298 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006299 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6300 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006301 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006302 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006303 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6304 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006305 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006306 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6307 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6308 return QualType();
6309 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006310
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006311 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6312 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006313 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006314 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006315 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes6fea8d22008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006316 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006317 // As above.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006318 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6319 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006320 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6321 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6322 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006323 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006324 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006325
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006326 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6327 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6328 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6329 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6330 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6331 }
6332
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006333 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006334 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6335 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006336 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6337}
6338
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006339/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006340QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006341 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6342 return Context.DependentTy;
6343
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006344 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006345 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6346 QualType Result;
6347
6348 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6349 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6350 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6351 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6352 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6353 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6354 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6355 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6356 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006357
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006358 if (Result.isNull()) {
6359 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6360 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6361 return QualType();
6362 }
6363
6364 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006365}
6366
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006367static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006368 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006369 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006370 switch (Kind) {
6371 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006372 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6373 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6374 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6375 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6376 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6377 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6378 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6379 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6380 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6381 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6382 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6383 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6384 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6385 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6386 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6387 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6388 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6389 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6390 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6391 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6392 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6393 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6394 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6395 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6396 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6397 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6398 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6399 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6400 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6401 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6402 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6403 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006404 }
6405 return Opc;
6406}
6407
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006408static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006409 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006410 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006411 switch (Kind) {
6412 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006413 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6414 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6415 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6416 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6417 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6418 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6419 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6420 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6421 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6422 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6423 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006424 }
6425 return Opc;
6426}
6427
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006428/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6429/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6430/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006431ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006432 unsigned Op,
6433 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006434 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006435 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006436 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6437 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6438 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006439
6440 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006441 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006442 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6443 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006444 case BO_PtrMemD:
6445 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006446 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006447 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006448 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006449 case BO_Mul:
6450 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006451 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006452 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006453 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006454 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006455 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6456 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006457 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006458 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6459 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006460 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006461 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6462 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006463 case BO_Shl:
6464 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006465 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6466 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006467 case BO_LE:
6468 case BO_LT:
6469 case BO_GE:
6470 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006471 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006472 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006473 case BO_EQ:
6474 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006475 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006476 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006477 case BO_And:
6478 case BO_Xor:
6479 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006480 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6481 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006482 case BO_LAnd:
6483 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006484 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006485 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006486 case BO_MulAssign:
6487 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006488 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006489 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006490 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6491 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6492 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006493 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006494 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006495 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6496 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6497 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6498 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006499 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006500 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006501 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6502 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6503 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006504 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006505 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006506 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6507 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6508 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006509 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006510 case BO_ShlAssign:
6511 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006512 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6513 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6514 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6515 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006516 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006517 case BO_AndAssign:
6518 case BO_XorAssign:
6519 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006520 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6521 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6522 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6523 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006524 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006525 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006526 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6527 break;
6528 }
6529 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006530 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006531 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006532 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006533 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6534 << ResultTy;
6535 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006536 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006537 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6538 else
6539 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006540 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6541 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006542}
6543
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006544/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6545/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006546static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6547 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006548 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6549 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6550 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006551 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006552 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6553
6554 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6555 return;
6556
6557 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6558 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6559 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006560 return;
6561 }
6562
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006563 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6564 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006565 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006566
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006567 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006568 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006569
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006570 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6571 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6572 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6573 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006574 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006575 return;
6576 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006577
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006578 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006579 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6580 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006581}
6582
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006583/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6584/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6585/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6586/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006587static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006588 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006589 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6590 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6591 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6592 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006593 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006594 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006595 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6596
6597 // Subs are not binary operators.
6598 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6599 return;
6600
6601 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6602 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006603 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6604 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006605 return;
6606
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006607 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006608 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006609 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006610 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6611 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006612 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006613 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006614 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6615 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6616 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6617 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006618 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006619 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006620 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006621 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6622 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006623 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006624 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006625 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6626 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6627 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6628 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006629}
6630
6631/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6632/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6633/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006634static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006635 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006636 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006637 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6638}
6639
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006640// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006641ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006642 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6643 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6644 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006645 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6646 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006647
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006648 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6649 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6650
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006651 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6652}
6653
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006654ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006655 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6656 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006657 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006658 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006659 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6660 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6661 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6662 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6663 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006664 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006665 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006666 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6667 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6668 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006669
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006670 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6671 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006672 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006673 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006674
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006675 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006676 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006677}
6678
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006679ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006680 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006681 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006682 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006683
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006684 QualType resultType;
6685 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006686 case UO_PreInc:
6687 case UO_PreDec:
6688 case UO_PostInc:
6689 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006690 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006691 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6692 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6693 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6694 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006695 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006696 case UO_AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006697 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6698 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006699 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006700 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006701 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6702 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006703 case UO_Plus:
6704 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006705 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6706 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006707 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6708 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006709 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6710 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006711 break;
6712 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6713 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6714 break;
6715 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006716 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006717 resultType->isPointerType())
6718 break;
6719
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006720 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6721 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006722 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006723 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6724 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006725 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6726 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006727 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6728 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6729 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006730 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006731 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006732 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006733 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6734 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006735 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006736 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006737 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006738 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006739 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006740 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6741 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006742 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006743 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6744 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006745 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006746 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6747 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006748 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006749 case UO_Real:
6750 case UO_Imag:
6751 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006752 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006753 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006754 resultType = Input->getType();
6755 break;
6756 }
6757 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006758 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006759
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006760 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006761}
6762
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006763ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006764 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6765 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006766 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006767 Opc != UO_Extension) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006768 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6769 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6770 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6771 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006772 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006773 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006774 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6775 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6776 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006777
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006778 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006779 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006780
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006781 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006782}
6783
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006784// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006785ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006786 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6787 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006788}
6789
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006790/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006791ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006792 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6793 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006794 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006795 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006796
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006797 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6798 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006799 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006800 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006801
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006802 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006803 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6804 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006805}
6806
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006807ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006808Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006809 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006810 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6811 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6812
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006813 bool isFileScope
6814 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006815 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006816 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006817
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006818 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6819 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6820 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006821
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006822 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6823 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6824 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006825
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006826 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6827 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6828 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6829 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6830 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006831
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006832 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006833 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006834 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006835
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006836 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6837 // expressions are not lvalues.
6838
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006839 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006840}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006841
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006842ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006843 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006844 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6845 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006846 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6847 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006848 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006849 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006850
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006851 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6852 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6853 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006854 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006855 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6856 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6857
6858 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6859 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6860 if (!Dependent
6861 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6862 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6863 << TypeRange))
6864 return ExprError();
6865
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006866 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6867 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006868 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6869 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006870 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006871 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6872 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006873
6874 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6875 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6876 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6877 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6878 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6879 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6880 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6881 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6882 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6883 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6884 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6885 if(!AT)
6886 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6887 << CurrentType);
6888 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6889 } else
6890 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6891
6892 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6893 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6894 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6895 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6896 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6897 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6898 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6899 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6900
6901 // Record this array index.
6902 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6903 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6904 continue;
6905 }
6906
6907 // Offset of a field.
6908 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6909 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6910 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6911 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6912 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6913 continue;
6914 }
6915
6916 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6917 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6918 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6919 return ExprError();
6920
6921 // Look for the designated field.
6922 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6923 if (!RC)
6924 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6925 << CurrentType);
6926 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6927
6928 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6929 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6930 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6931 // (clause 9).
6932 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6933 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6934 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6935 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6936 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6937 << CurrentType))
6938 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6939 }
6940
6941 // Look for the field.
6942 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6943 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6944 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6945 if (!MemberDecl)
6946 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6947 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6948 OC.LocEnd));
6949
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006950 // C99 7.17p3:
6951 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6952 //
6953 // We diagnose this as an error.
6954 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6955 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6956 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6957 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6958 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6959 return ExprError();
6960 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006961
6962 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
6963 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
6964 if (AnonStructUnion) {
6965 do {
6966 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
6967 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
6968 }
6969
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006970 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6971 // the base class indirections.
6972 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6973 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006974 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006975 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6976 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6977 B != BEnd; ++B)
6978 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6979 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006980
6981 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006982 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6983 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6984 unsigned n = Path.size();
6985 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6986 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6987 } else {
6988 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6989 }
6990 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6991 }
6992
6993 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6994 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6995 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6996}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006997
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006998ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006999 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7000 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007001 ParsedType argty,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007002 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7003 unsigned NumComponents,
7004 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7005
7006 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7007 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7008 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7009 return ExprError();
7010
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007011 if (!ArgTInfo)
7012 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7013
7014 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7015 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007016}
7017
7018
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007019ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007020 ParsedType arg1,ParsedType arg2,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007021 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007022 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7023 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7024 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7025 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007026
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007027 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007028
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007029 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7030}
7031
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007032ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007033Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7034 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7035 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7036 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007037 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7038 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7039 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7040 return ExprError();
7041 }
7042
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007043 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007044 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007045}
7046
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007047
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007048ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007049 Expr *CondExpr,
7050 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007051 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007052 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7053
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007054 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007055 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007056 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007057 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007058 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007059 } else {
7060 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7061 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7062 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7063 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007064 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7065 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7066 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007067
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007068 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7069 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007070 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7071 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007072 }
7073
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007074 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007075 resType, RPLoc,
7076 resType->isDependentType(),
7077 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007078}
7079
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007080//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7081// Clang Extensions.
7082//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7083
7084/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007085void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007086 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7087 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7088 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007089 if (BlockScope)
7090 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7091 else
7092 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007093}
7094
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007095void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007096 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007097 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007098
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007099 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007100 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007101 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007102
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007103 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007104 QualType RetTy;
7105 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007106 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007107 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007108 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007109 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7110 } else {
7111 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007112 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007113 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007114
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007115 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007116
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007117 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7118 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7119 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007120 return;
7121 }
7122
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007123 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7124 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7125 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7126 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7127 return;
7128 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007129
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007130 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007131 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7132 // ^ * { ... }
7133 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007134 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7135 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007136
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007137 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007138 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007139 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7140 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7141 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7142 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007143 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7144 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7145 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7146 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7147 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007148 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007149 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007150
7151 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7152 // ^ fntype { ... }
7153 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7154 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7155 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7156 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7157 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7158 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7159 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007160 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007161 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007162 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007163
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007164 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7165 if (!Params.empty())
7166 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007167
7168 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007169 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007170
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007171 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007172 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7173 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7174 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7175 }
7176
7177 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7178 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007179 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007180 return;
7181
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007182 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7183 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7184
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007185 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007186 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7187 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7188
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007189 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007190 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7191 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7192 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7193
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007194 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007195 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007196 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007197}
7198
7199/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7200/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7201void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007202 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007203 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007204 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007205 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007206}
7207
7208/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7209/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007210ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007211 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007212 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7213 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7214 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007215
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007216 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007217
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007218 PopDeclContext();
7219
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007220 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007221 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7222 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007223
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007224 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007225 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007226
7227 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7228 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7229 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7230
7231 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7232 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7233
7234 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7235 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7236 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7237 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7238
7239 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7240 // preserve its sugar structure.
7241 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7242 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7243 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7244
7245 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7246 } else {
7247 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7248 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7249 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7250 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7251 FPT->isVariadic(),
7252 /*quals*/ 0,
7253 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7254 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7255 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7256 FPT->exception_begin(),
7257 Ext);
7258 }
7259
7260 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7261 } else {
7262 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7263 false, false, 0, 0,
7264 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7265 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007266
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007267 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007268 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7269 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007270 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007271
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007272 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007273 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007274 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007275
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007276 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007277
7278 bool Good = true;
7279 // Check goto/label use.
7280 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7281 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7282 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7283
7284 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7285 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7286 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7287 continue;
7288
7289 // Emit error.
7290 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7291 Good = false;
7292 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007293 if (!Good) {
7294 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007295 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007296 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007297
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007298 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7299 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7300
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007301 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007302 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7303 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007304 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007305
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007306 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007307 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007308}
7309
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007310ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007311 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007312 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007313 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7314 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007315 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007316}
7317
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007318ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007319 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007320 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007321 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007322
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007323 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007324
7325 // Get the va_list type
7326 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007327 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7328 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7329 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7330 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007331 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007332 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7333 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7334 } else {
7335 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7336 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007337 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007338 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007339 return ExprError();
7340 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007341
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007342 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7343 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007344 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7345 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007346 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007347 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007348
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007349 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007350 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007351
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007352 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7353 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007354}
7355
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007356ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007357 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7358 // pointers on the target.
7359 QualType Ty;
7360 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7361 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7362 else
7363 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7364
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007365 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007366}
7367
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007368static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007369 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007370 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7371 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007372
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007373 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7374 if (!PT)
7375 return;
7376
7377 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7378 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7379 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7380 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7381 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7382 return;
7383 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007384
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007385 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7386 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7387 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7388 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007389
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007390 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007391}
7392
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007393bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7394 SourceLocation Loc,
7395 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007396 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7397 bool *Complained) {
7398 if (Complained)
7399 *Complained = false;
7400
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007401 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7402 bool isInvalid = false;
7403 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007404 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007405
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007406 switch (ConvTy) {
7407 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7408 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007409 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007410 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7411 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007412 case IntToPointer:
7413 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7414 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007415 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007416 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007417 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7418 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007419 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7420 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7421 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007422 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7423 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7424 break;
7425 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007426 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7427 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7428 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7429 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7430 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7431 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7432 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7433 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7434 // C++ semantics.
7435 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7436 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7437 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007438 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7439 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007440 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007441 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007442 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007443 case IntToBlockPointer:
7444 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7445 break;
7446 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007447 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007448 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007449 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007450 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007451 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7452 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7453 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007454 case IncompatibleVectors:
7455 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7456 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007457 case Incompatible:
7458 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7459 isInvalid = true;
7460 break;
7461 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007462
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007463 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7464 switch (Action) {
7465 case AA_Assigning:
7466 case AA_Initializing:
7467 // The destination type comes first.
7468 FirstType = DstType;
7469 SecondType = SrcType;
7470 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007471
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007472 case AA_Returning:
7473 case AA_Passing:
7474 case AA_Converting:
7475 case AA_Sending:
7476 case AA_Casting:
7477 // The source type comes first.
7478 FirstType = SrcType;
7479 SecondType = DstType;
7480 break;
7481 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007482
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007483 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007484 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007485 if (Complained)
7486 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007487 return isInvalid;
7488}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007489
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007490bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007491 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7492 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7493 if (Result)
7494 *Result = ICEResult;
7495 return false;
7496 }
7497
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007498 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7499
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007500 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007501 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7502 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7503
7504 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7505 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7506 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7507 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7508 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7509 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7510 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007511
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007512 return true;
7513 }
7514
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007515 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7516 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007517
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007518 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7519 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7520 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007521
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007522 if (Result)
7523 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7524 return false;
7525}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007526
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007527void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007528Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007529 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7530 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007531}
7532
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007533void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007534Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7535 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7536 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7537 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007538
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007539 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7540 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7541 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7542 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7543 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007544 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007545 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7546 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7547 I != IEnd; ++I)
7548 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7549 }
7550
7551 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7552 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7553 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7554 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7555 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7556 I != IEnd; ++I)
7557 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7558 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007559 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007560
7561 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7562 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7563 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7564 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007565 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007566 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7567 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7568 ExprTemporaries.end());
7569
7570 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7571 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007572}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007573
7574/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7575///
7576/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7577/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7578/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7579/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7580///
7581/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7582///
7583/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7584void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7585 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007586
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007587 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007588 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007589
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007590 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7591 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7592 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7593 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007594 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007595 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007596 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007597 return;
7598 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007599
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007600 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7601 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007602
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007603 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7604 // an instantiation.
7605 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7606 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007607
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007608 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007609 case Unevaluated:
7610 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7611 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007612
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007613 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7614 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7615 // "used"; handle this below.
7616 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007617
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007618 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7619 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7620 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7621 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007622 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007623 return;
7624 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007625
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007626 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007627 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007628 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007629 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007630 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7631 return;
7632 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7633 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007634 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007635 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007636 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007637 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7638 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007639
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007640 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007641 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007642 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007643 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007644 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7645 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007646 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7647 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7648 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007649 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007650 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007651 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7652 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007653 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007654 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007655 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007656 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007657 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007658 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7659 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7660 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7661 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7662 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007663 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007664 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007665 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007666 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007667 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7668 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7669 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007670 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007671 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007672 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7673 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007674
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007675 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7676 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7677 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7678 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7679 Loc));
7680 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007681 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007682 }
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007683 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007684
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007685 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007686
7687 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7688 if (CurContext != Function)
7689 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007690
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007691 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007692 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007693
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007694 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007695 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007696 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007697 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7698 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7699 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7700 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7701 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7702 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007703 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007704 }
7705 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007706
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007707 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007708
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007709 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007710 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007711 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007712}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007713
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007714namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007715 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007716 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007717 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007718 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7719 Sema &S;
7720 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007721
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007722 public:
7723 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007724
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007725 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007726
7727 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7728 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007729 };
7730}
7731
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007732bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7733 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007734 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7735 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7736 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007737
7738 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007739}
7740
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007741bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007742 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7743 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7744 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007745 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7746 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007747 }
7748
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007749 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007750}
7751
7752void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7753 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007754 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007755}
7756
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007757/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7758/// of the program being compiled.
7759///
7760/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007761/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007762/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7763/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7764/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7765/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007766/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007767/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007768///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007769/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7770/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7771/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7772/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007773bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007774 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7775 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7776 case Unevaluated:
7777 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7778 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007779
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007780 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7781 Diag(Loc, PD);
7782 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007783
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007784 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7785 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7786 break;
7787 }
7788
7789 return false;
7790}
7791
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007792bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7793 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7794 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7795 return false;
7796
7797 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7798 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7799 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7800 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007801
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007802 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007803 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007804 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7805 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007806 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007807 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7808 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7809 return true;
7810
7811 return false;
7812}
7813
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007814// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7815// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7816void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7817 SourceLocation Loc;
7818
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007819 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7820
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007821 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7822 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007823 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007824 return;
7825
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007826 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7827 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7828 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7829 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7830
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007831 // self = [<foo> init...]
7832 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7833 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7834 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7835
7836 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7837 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7838 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7839 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7840 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007841
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007842 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7843 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7844 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7845 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7846 return;
7847
7848 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7849 } else {
7850 // Not an assignment.
7851 return;
7852 }
7853
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007854 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007855 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007856
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007857 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007858 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007859 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007860 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7861 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7862 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007863}
7864
7865bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7866 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7867
7868 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007869 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007870
7871 QualType T = E->getType();
7872
7873 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7874 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7875 return true;
7876 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7877 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7878 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7879 return true;
7880 }
7881 }
7882
7883 return false;
7884}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007885
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007886ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7887 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007888 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007889 return ExprError();
7890
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007891 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007892 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007893
7894 return Owned(Sub);
7895}